blob: 8643dd8386d3c9f6bf2c31ce2ec3049d6e83d14c [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000014#include "clang/Sema/Sema.h"
15#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000032#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner07d754a2008-10-26 23:43:26 +000033#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000034#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregorb53edfb2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000035#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000036using namespace clang;
37
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000038
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000039/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
40/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
41///
42/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
43/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
44/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
45/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
46/// function is being used.
47///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000048/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
49/// decls.
50///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000051/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
52/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000053///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000054bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000055 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000056 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 }
59
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000060 // See if the decl is unavailable
61 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
Ted Kremenek1ddd6d22010-07-21 20:43:11 +000062 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000063 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
64 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000065
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000066 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000067 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000068 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
69 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
70 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
71 return true;
72 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000073 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000076}
77
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000078/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000080/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
81///
82void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000084 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000086 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000087
88 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
89 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
91 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000093 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
94 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000095 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +000096 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
97 int isMethod = 0;
98 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
99 // skip over named parameters.
100 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
101 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
102 if (nullPos)
103 --nullPos;
104 else
105 ++i;
106 }
107 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
108 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000109 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000110 // skip over named parameters.
111 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
112 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
113 if (nullPos)
114 --nullPos;
115 else
116 ++i;
117 }
118 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000119 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000120 // block or function pointer call.
121 QualType Ty = V->getType();
122 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000123 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000124 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
125 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000126 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
127 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
128 unsigned k;
129 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
130 if (nullPos)
131 --nullPos;
132 else
133 ++i;
134 }
135 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
136 }
137 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
138 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000139 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000140 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000141 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000142 return;
143
144 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000145 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000147 return;
148 }
149 int sentinel = i;
150 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
151 --sentinelPos;
152 ++i;
153 }
154 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
155 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000156 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000157 return;
158 }
159 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
160 ++i;
161 ++sentinel;
162 }
163 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000164 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
165 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
166 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanianc0b0ced2010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000167 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000168 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
169 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
170 return;
171
172 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
173 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
174
175 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
176 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000177}
178
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000179SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
180 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
181 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
182}
183
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000184//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
185// Standard Promotions and Conversions
186//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
187
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
189void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
190 QualType Ty = E->getType();
191 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
192
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000193 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000194 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlsson6904f642009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000195 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000196 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
197 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
198 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
199 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
200 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
201 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
202 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000203 //
204 // C++ 4.2p1:
205 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
206 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
207 //
208 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
209 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000210 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
211 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000212 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213}
214
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000215void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
216 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218 QualType Ty = E->getType();
219 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
220 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
221 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
222 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
223 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
224 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
225 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
226 // rvalue is T
227 //
228 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000229 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
230 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000231 // type of the lvalue.
232 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
233 }
234}
235
236
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000237/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000239/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
240/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
241/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
242Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
243 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000246 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
247 //
248 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
249 // unsigned int may be used:
250 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
251 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
252 // and unsigned int.
253 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
254 //
255 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
256 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
257 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
258 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000259 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
260 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 return Expr;
263 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000264 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000265 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000266 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000268 }
269
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000270 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000271 return Expr;
272}
273
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000274/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000275/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
277void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
278 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
279 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000280
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000282 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
283 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
284 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000285
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000286 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
287}
288
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000289/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
290/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
291/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
292/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000293bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
294 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000295 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000296
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000297 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
298 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
299 // etc.
300 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
301 return false;
302
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000303 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000304 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
305 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
306 << Expr->getType() << CT))
307 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000308
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000309 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000310 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
312 << Expr->getType() << CT))
313 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314
315 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000316}
317
318
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000319/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
320/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
323/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
324/// GCC.
325QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
326 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000327 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000328 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000329
330 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000331
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000332 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000333 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000334 QualType lhs =
335 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000336 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
339 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
340 if (lhs == rhs)
341 return lhs;
342
343 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
344 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
345 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
346 return lhs;
347
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000348 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000349 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000350 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
351 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
355
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000356 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000357 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000358 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
359 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360 return destType;
361}
362
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000363//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
364// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
365//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
366
367
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000368/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000369/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
370/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
371/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
372/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000373///
374Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000376 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
377
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000378 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000379 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000381
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000382 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000383 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
384 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000385
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000386 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000387 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000389
390 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattnera8687ae2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000393
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000394 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
395 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
396 // strings.
397 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000398 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000399 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000400
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000401 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000402 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattnerf83b5af2009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000403 Literal.GetStringLength(),
404 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
405 &StringTokLocs[0],
406 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000407}
408
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000409/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
410/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
411/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
412/// for values inside the block or for globals).
413///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000414/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000415/// up-to-date.
416///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000417static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000418 ValueDecl *VD) {
419 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
420 // we wanted to.
421 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
422 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000423
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000424 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
425 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
426 return false;
427
428 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
429 // snapshot it.
430 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
431 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000432 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
433 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000434
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
436 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
437
438 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
439 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
440 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
441 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
443 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000444
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 if (!NextBlock)
446 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
449 // having a reference outside it.
450 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000453 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
454 // a snapshot as well.
455 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
456 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000457
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000458 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000462Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000463Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000464 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000465 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
466 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
467}
468
469/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
470Sema::OwningExprResult
471Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
472 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
473 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000474 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000475 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000476 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000477 << D->getDeclName();
478 return ExprError();
479 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000480
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000481 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000482 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
483 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
484 // visible.
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000485 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000486 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000487 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
488 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000489 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
490 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000491 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000492 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000493 << D->getIdentifier();
494 return ExprError();
495 }
496 }
497 }
498 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000499
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000500 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000501
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000502 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
503 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
504 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000505 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000506}
507
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000508/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
509/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
510/// actual member.
511///
512/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
513/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
514/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
515/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
516/// we found.
517///
518/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
519/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
520/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
521VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
522 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000523 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
524 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
525 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
526
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000527 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000528 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
529 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
530 do {
531 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000532 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000533 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000534 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000535 else {
536 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
537 break;
538 }
539 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000540 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000541 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000542
543 return BaseObject;
544}
545
546Sema::OwningExprResult
547Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
548 FieldDecl *Field,
549 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
550 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
551 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000552 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000553 AnonFields);
554
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000555 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
556 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
557 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
558 // found via name lookup.
559 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000560 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000561 if (BaseObject) {
562 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
563 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000564 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000565 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000566 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000567 BaseQuals
568 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000569 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
570 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
571 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
572 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
573 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000574 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000575 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
576 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
577 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000578 BaseQuals
579 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000580 } else {
581 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
582 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
583 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000584 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
585 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000586 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000587 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000588 = Context.getTagDeclType(
589 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
590 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000591 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000592 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
593 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
594 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000595 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000596 MD->getThisType(Context),
597 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000598 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
599 }
600 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000601 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
602 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000603 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000604 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000605 }
606
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000607 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000608 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
609 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000610 }
611
612 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
613 // anonymous struct/union.
614 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000615 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000616 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
617 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
618 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
619 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000620 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
621 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
622
623 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
624 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
625 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
626 ResultQuals.removeConst();
627
628 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
629 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
630
631 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
632 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
633
634 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
635 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
636 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
637
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000638 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000639 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000640 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000641 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
642 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000643 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000644 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000645 }
646
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000647 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000648}
649
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000650/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000651/// possibly a list of template arguments.
652///
653/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
654/// DecomposeTemplateName.
655///
656/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
657/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
658/// some way.
659static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
660 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
661 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000662 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000663 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
664 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
665 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
666 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
667
668 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
669 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
670 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
671 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
672 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
673
674 TemplateName TName =
675 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000676 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
677 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000678 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
679 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000680 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000681 TemplateArgs = 0;
682 }
683}
684
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000685/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
686/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
687/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000688static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000689 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
690 return false;
691
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000692 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
693 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
694 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
695 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
696 if (!BaseRT) return false;
697
698 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000699 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000700 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
701 return false;
702 }
703
704 return true;
705}
706
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000707/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
708/// the prospective base classes.
709static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
710 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
711 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000712 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000713 return false;
714
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000715 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000716 if (!RD) return false;
717 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
718
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000719 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
720 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
721 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
722 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
723 if (!BaseRT) return false;
724
725 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000726 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
727 return false;
728 }
729
730 return true;
731}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000732
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000733enum IMAKind {
734 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
735 IMA_Static,
736
737 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
738 IMA_Mixed,
739
740 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
741 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
742 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
743
744 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
745 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
746 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
747
748 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
749 IMA_Instance,
750
751 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
752 IMA_Unresolved,
753
754 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
755 /// context is not an instance method.
756 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
757
758 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
759 /// non-class context.
760 IMA_AnonymousMember,
761
762 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
763 /// context is not an instance method.
764 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
765
766 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
767 /// class.
768 IMA_Error_Unrelated
769};
770
771/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
772/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
773/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
774/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
775/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
776/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
777static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
778 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000779 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000780
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000781 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000782 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000783 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
784 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000785
786 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
787 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
788
789 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
790 bool hasNonInstance = false;
791 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
792 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000793 NamedDecl *D = *I;
794 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000795 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
796
797 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
798 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
799 // that's a special case.
800 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
801 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
802 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
803 }
804 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
805 }
806 else
807 hasNonInstance = true;
808 }
809
810 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
811 // member reference.
812 if (Classes.empty())
813 return IMA_Static;
814
815 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
816 // an implicit member reference.
817 if (isStaticContext)
818 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
819
820 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
821 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
822 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
823 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000824 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000825 Classes))
826 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
827
828 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
829}
830
831/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
832static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
833 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
834 const LookupResult &R) {
835 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
836 SourceRange Range(Loc);
837 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
838
839 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
840 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
841 if (MD->isStatic()) {
842 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
843 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
844 << Range << R.getLookupName();
845 return;
846 }
847 }
848
849 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
850 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
851 return;
852 }
853
854 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000855}
856
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000857/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
858///
859/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000860bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
861 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000862 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
863
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000864 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000865 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000866 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
867 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000868 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000869 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000870 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
871 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000872
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000873 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
874 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
875 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
876 // dependent name.
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000877 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000878 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000879 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
880 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
881
882 if (!R.empty()) {
883 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
884 R.suppressDiagnostics();
885
886 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
887 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
888 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
889 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
890
891 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
892 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
893 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000894 if (isInstance) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000895 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000896 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000897
898 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
899 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
900 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(
901 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
902 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
903 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(R.getNameLoc(),
904 DepThisType, false);
905 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
906 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
907 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
908 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
909 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
910 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000911 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
912 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000913 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
914 } else {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000915 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000916 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000917
918 // Do we really want to note all of these?
919 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
920 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
921
922 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
923 return false;
924 }
Douglas Gregor86b8d9f2010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000925
926 R.clear();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000927 }
928 }
929
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000930 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000931 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000932 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000933 if (!R.empty()) {
934 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
935 if (SS.isEmpty())
936 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
937 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
938 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
939 else
940 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
941 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
942 << SS.getRange()
943 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
944 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
945 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
946 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
947 << ND->getDeclName();
948
949 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
950 return false;
951 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000952
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000953 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
954 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
955 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
956 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
957 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
958 // to recover well anyway.
959 if (SS.isEmpty())
960 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
961 else
962 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
963 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
964 << SS.getRange();
965
966 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
967 return true;
968 }
969 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000970 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000971 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000972 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000973 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000974 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000975 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000976 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
977 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000978 return true;
979 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000980 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000981 }
982
983 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
984 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
985 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
986 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
987 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
988 << SS.getRange();
989 return true;
990 }
991
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000992 // Give up, we can't recover.
993 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
994 return true;
995}
996
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +0000997static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +0000998 IdentifierInfo *II,
999 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001000 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1001 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1002 if (!IDecl)
1003 return 0;
1004 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1005 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1006 return 0;
1007 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1008 if (!property)
1009 return 0;
1010 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1011 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1012 return 0;
1013 return property;
1014}
1015
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001016static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001017 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001018 IdentifierInfo *II,
1019 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1020 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001021 bool LookForIvars;
1022 if (Lookup.empty())
1023 LookForIvars = true;
1024 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1025 LookForIvars = false;
1026 else
1027 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1028 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1029 if (!LookForIvars)
1030 return 0;
1031
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001032 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1033 if (!IDecl)
1034 return 0;
1035 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001036 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1037 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001038 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1039 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1040 if (!property)
1041 return 0;
1042 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1043 DynamicImplSeen =
1044 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
1045 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001046 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1047 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001048 NameLoc,
1049 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1050 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1051 (Expr *)0, true);
1052 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1053 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1054 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1055 return Ivar;
1056 }
1057 return 0;
1058}
1059
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001060Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001061 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001062 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1063 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1064 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1065 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1066 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1067
1068 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001069 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001070
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001071 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001072
1073 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001074 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001075 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001076 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001077
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001078 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001079 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001080 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001081
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001082 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1083 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001084 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1085 // (note: handled after lookup)
1086 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1087 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1088 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001089 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1090 // names a dependent type.
1091 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1092 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman964dbda2010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001093 bool DependentID = false;
1094 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1095 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1096 DependentID = true;
1097 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1098 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1099 if (DC) {
1100 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1101 return ExprError();
1102 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1103 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1104 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1105 } else {
1106 DependentID = true;
1107 }
1108 }
1109
1110 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001111 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001112 TemplateArgs);
1113 }
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001114 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001115 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001116 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001117 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001118 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1119 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1120 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1121 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1122 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001123 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1124 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1125 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001126 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001127 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001128 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001129
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001130 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1131 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001132 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1133 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001134 if (E.isInvalid())
1135 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001136
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001137 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1138 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001139 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1140 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001141 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001142 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1143 isAddressOfOperand);
1144 }
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001145 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001146 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001147
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001148 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1149 return ExprError();
1150
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001151 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1152 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001153 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001154
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001155 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001156 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001157 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1158 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1159 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1160 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1161 }
1162
1163 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1164 // call, diagnose the problem.
1165 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001166 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001167 return ExprError();
1168
1169 assert(!R.empty() &&
1170 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001171
1172 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1173 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001174 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001175 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1176 R.clear();
1177 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1178 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1179 return move(E);
1180 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001181 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001182 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001183
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001184 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1185 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1186
1187 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001188 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianc15dfd82010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001189 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1190 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001191 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1192 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1193 if (Property) {
1194 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1195 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
1196 }
1197 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001198 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001199 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1200 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1201 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1202 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1203 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1204 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001205 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001206 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001207
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001208 QualType T = Func->getType();
1209 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001210 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001211 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1212 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001213 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001214 }
1215 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001216
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001217 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1218 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1219 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1220 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1221 // class member access expression.
1222 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1223 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001224 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001225 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001226 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1227 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001228 }
1229
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001230 if (TemplateArgs)
1231 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001232
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001233 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1234}
1235
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001236/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1237Sema::OwningExprResult
1238Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1239 LookupResult &R,
1240 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1241 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1242 case IMA_Instance:
1243 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1244
1245 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1246 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1247 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1248 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1249
1250 case IMA_Mixed:
1251 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1252 case IMA_Unresolved:
1253 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1254
1255 case IMA_Static:
1256 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1257 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1258 if (TemplateArgs)
1259 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1260 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1261
1262 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1263 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1264 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1265 return ExprError();
1266 }
1267
1268 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1269 return ExprError();
1270}
1271
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001272/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1273/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1274/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1275/// this path.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001276Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001277Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001278 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001279 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001280 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001281 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001282
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001283 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001284 return ExprError();
1285
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001286 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001287 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1288
1289 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1290 return ExprError();
1291
1292 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001293 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1294 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001295 return ExprError();
1296 }
1297
1298 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1299}
1300
1301/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1302/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1303/// additional lookup.
1304///
1305/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1306/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1307///
1308/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1309Sema::OwningExprResult
1310Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001311 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001312 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001313 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001314
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001315 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1316 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1317 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1318 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1319 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1320
1321 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1322 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1323 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001324 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001325
1326 bool LookForIvars;
1327 if (Lookup.empty())
1328 LookForIvars = true;
1329 else if (IsClassMethod)
1330 LookForIvars = false;
1331 else
1332 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1333 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001334 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001335 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001336 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001337 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1338 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1339 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1340 if (IsClassMethod)
1341 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1342 << IV->getDeclName());
1343
1344 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1345 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1346 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1347 return ExprError();
1348
1349 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1350 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1351 return ExprError();
1352
1353 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1354 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1355 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1356 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1357
1358 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1359 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1360 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1361 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001362 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001363 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1364 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1365 SelfName, false, false);
1366 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1367 return Owned(new (Context)
1368 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1369 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1370 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001371 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001372 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001373 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001374 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1375 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1376 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1377 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1378 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1379 }
1380 }
1381
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001382 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1383 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1384 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1385 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1386 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1387 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1388 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1389 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1390 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1391 }
1392 }
1393 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001394 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1395 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001396}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001397
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001398/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1399///
1400/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1401///
1402/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1403/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1404/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1405/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1406///
1407/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1408/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1409/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1410/// the class declaring the member.
1411///
1412/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1413/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1414/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001415bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001416Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1417 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001418 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001419 NamedDecl *Member) {
1420 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1421 if (!RD)
1422 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001423
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001424 QualType DestRecordType;
1425 QualType DestType;
1426 QualType FromRecordType;
1427 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1428 bool PointerConversions = false;
1429 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1430 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001431
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001432 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1433 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1434 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1435 PointerConversions = true;
1436 } else {
1437 DestType = DestRecordType;
1438 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001439 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001440 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1441 if (Method->isStatic())
1442 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001443
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001444 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1445 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001446
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001447 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1448 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1449 PointerConversions = true;
1450 } else {
1451 FromRecordType = FromType;
1452 DestType = DestRecordType;
1453 }
1454 } else {
1455 // No conversion necessary.
1456 return false;
1457 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001458
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001459 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1460 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001461
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001462 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1463 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1464 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001465
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001466 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1467 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1468
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001469 ImplicitCastExpr::ResultCategory Category = CastCategory(From);
1470
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001471 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001472 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001473 // class name.
1474 //
1475 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1476 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1477 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1478 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1479 //
1480 // class Base { public: int x; };
1481 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1482 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1483 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1484 //
1485 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1486 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1487 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1488 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001489 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001490 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1491 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1492 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1493
1494 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1495
1496 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1497 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1498 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1499 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001500 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001501 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001502 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001503 return true;
1504
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001505 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001506 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001507 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001508 Category, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001509
1510 FromType = QType;
1511 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1512
1513 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1514 // we're done.
1515 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1516 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001517 }
1518 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001519
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001520 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001521
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001522 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1523 // down to the using declaration's type.
1524 //
1525 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1526 // class ever has member declarations.
1527 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1528 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1529 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1530 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1531
1532 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1533 // conversion is non-trivial.
1534 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1535 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001536 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001537 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001538 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001539 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001540
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001541 QualType UType = URecordType;
1542 if (PointerConversions)
1543 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001544 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001545 Category, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001546 FromType = UType;
1547 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1548 }
1549
1550 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1551 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1552 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001553 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001554
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001555 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001556 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1557 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001558 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001559 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001560
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001561 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001562 Category, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001563 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001564}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001565
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001566/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001567static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001568 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001569 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001570 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1571 QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001572 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1573 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1574 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001575 if (SS.isSet()) {
1576 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1577 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001578 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001579
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001580 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001581 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1582 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001583}
1584
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001585/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1586/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1587/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1588/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001589Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001590Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1591 LookupResult &R,
1592 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1593 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001594 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1595
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001596 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001597
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001598 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1599 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001600 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001601 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001602 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001603 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001604 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001605
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001606 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1607 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001608 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1609 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001610 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1611 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001612 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1613 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1614 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1615 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001616 }
1617
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001618 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1619 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1620 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001621 SS,
1622 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1623 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001624}
1625
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001626bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001627 const LookupResult &R,
1628 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001629 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1630 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1631 return false;
1632
1633 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001634 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001635 return false;
1636
1637 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001638 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001639 return false;
1640
1641 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1642 // normal lookup:
1643 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1644 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1645
1646 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1647 // -- a declaration of a class member
1648 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1649 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001650 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001651 return false;
1652
1653 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1654 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1655 // using-declaration
1656 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1657 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1658 // turn off ADL anyway).
1659 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1660 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1661 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1662 return false;
1663
1664 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1665 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1666 // template
1667 // And also for builtin functions.
1668 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1669 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1670
1671 // But also builtin functions.
1672 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1673 return false;
1674 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1675 return false;
1676 }
1677
1678 return true;
1679}
1680
1681
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001682/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1683/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1684/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1685/// will in fact be used.
1686static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1687 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1688 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1689 return true;
1690 }
1691
1692 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1693 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1694 return true;
1695 }
1696
1697 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1698 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1699 return true;
1700 }
1701
1702 return false;
1703}
1704
1705Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001706Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001707 LookupResult &R,
1708 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001709 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1710 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001711 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001712 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1713 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001714
1715 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1716 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1717 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001718 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1719 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001720 return ExprError();
1721
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001722 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1723 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1724 // we've picked a target.
1725 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1726
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001727 bool Dependent
1728 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001729 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001730 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001731 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001732 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001733 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1734 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001735
1736 return Owned(ULE);
1737}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001738
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001739
1740/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1741Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001742Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001743 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1744 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001745 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001746 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1747 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001748
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001749 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001750 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1751 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001752
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001753 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1754 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1755 // a template argument list.
1756 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1757 << Template << SS.getRange();
1758 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1759 return ExprError();
1760 }
1761
1762 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1763 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1764 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001765 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001766 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001767 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001768 return ExprError();
1769 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001770
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001771 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1772 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1773 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1774 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001775 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001776 return ExprError();
1777
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001778 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1779 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001780 return ExprError();
1781
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001782 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1783 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1784 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1785 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001786 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001787 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1788 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1789 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001790 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001791 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001792 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1793 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1794 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1795 return ExprError();
1796 }
1797
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001798 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001799 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1800 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1801 return ExprError();
1802 }
1803
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001804 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001805 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001806 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001807 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001808 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001809 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1810 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001811 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001812
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001813 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian70c0b082010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001814 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001815 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1816 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanianc289bce2010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001817 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001818 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1819 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1820 Expr *E = new (Context)
1821 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1822 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001823
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001824 OwningExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
1825 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001826 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001827 SourceLocation(),
1828 Owned(E));
1829 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
1830 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(move(Res));
1831 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1832 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1833 }
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001834 }
1835 }
1836 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001837 }
1838 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1839 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001840
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001841 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1842 NameInfo, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001843}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001844
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001845Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1846 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001847 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001848
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001849 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001850 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001851 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1852 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1853 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001854 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001855
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001856 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1857 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001858
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001859 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian94627442010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001860 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1861 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001862 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001863 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001864 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001865 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001866
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001867 QualType ResTy;
1868 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1869 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1870 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001871 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001872
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001873 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001874 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001875 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1876 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001877 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001878}
1879
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001880Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001881 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001882 bool Invalid = false;
1883 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1884 if (Invalid)
1885 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001886
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001887 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1888 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001889 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001890 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001891
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001892 QualType Ty;
1893 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1894 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1895 else if (Literal.isWide())
1896 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001897 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1898 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001899 else
1900 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001901
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001902 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1903 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001904 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001905}
1906
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001907Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1908 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001909 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1910 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001911 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001912 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001913 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001914 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001915 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001916
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001917 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001918 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1919 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001920 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001921
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001922 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001923 bool Invalid = false;
1924 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1925 if (Invalid)
1926 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001927
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001928 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001929 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001930 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001931 return ExprError();
1932
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001933 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001934
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001935 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001936 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001937 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001938 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001939 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001940 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001941 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001942 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001943
1944 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1945
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001946 using llvm::APFloat;
1947 APFloat Val(Format);
1948
1949 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001950
1951 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1952 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1953 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1954 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001955 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001956 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001957 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001958 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001959 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1960 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001961 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001962 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1963 }
1964
1965 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1966 << Ty
1967 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1968 }
1969
1970 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattnere4edb8e2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001971 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001972
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001973 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001974 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001975 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001976 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001977
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001978 // long long is a C99 feature.
1979 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001980 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001981 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1982
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001983 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001984 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001985
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001986 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1987 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1988 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001989 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1990 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001991 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001992 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001993 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1994 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001995
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001996 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1997 // be an unsigned int.
1998 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1999
2000 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002001 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002002 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2003 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002004 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002005
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002006 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2007 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2008 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2009 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002010 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002011 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002012 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002013 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002014 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002015 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002016
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002017 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002018 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002019 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002020
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002021 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2022 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2023 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2024 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002025 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002026 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002027 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002028 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002029 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002030 }
2031
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002032 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002033 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002034 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002035
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002036 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2037 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2038 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2039 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002040 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002041 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002042 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002043 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002044 }
2045 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002046
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002047 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2048 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002049 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002050 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002051 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002052 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002053 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002054
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002055 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2056 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002057 }
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00002058 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002059 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002060
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002061 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2062 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002063 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002064 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002065
2066 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002067}
2068
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002069Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
2070 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00002071 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002072 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002073 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002074}
2075
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002076/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002077/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002078bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002079 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2080 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2081 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002082 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2083 return false;
2084
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002085 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2086 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2087 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2088 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2089 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2090 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2091
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002092 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002093 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002094 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002095 if (isSizeof)
2096 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2097 return false;
2098 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002099
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002100 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002101 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002102 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2103 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002104 return false;
2105 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002106
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002107 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002108 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2109 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002110 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002111
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002112 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002113 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002114 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002115 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2116 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002117 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002118
Douglas Gregor27887822010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002119 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2120 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2121 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2122 return true;
2123 }
2124
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002125 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002126}
2127
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002128bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2129 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2130 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002131
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002132 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002133 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2134 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002135
2136 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2137 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2138 return false;
2139
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002140 if (E->getBitField()) {
2141 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2142 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002143 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002144
2145 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2146 // bit-field.
2147 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002148 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002149 return false;
2150
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002151 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2152}
2153
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002154/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002155Action::OwningExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002156Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002157 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002158 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002159 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002160 return ExprError();
2161
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002162 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002163
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002164 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2165 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2166 return ExprError();
2167
2168 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002169 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002170 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2171 R.getEnd()));
2172}
2173
2174/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2175/// operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002176Action::OwningExprResult
2177Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002178 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2179 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2180 bool isInvalid = false;
2181 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2182 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2183 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2184 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002185 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002186 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2187 isInvalid = true;
2188 } else {
2189 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2190 }
2191
2192 if (isInvalid)
2193 return ExprError();
2194
2195 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2196 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2197 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2198 R.getEnd()));
2199}
2200
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002201/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2202/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2203/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002204Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002205Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2206 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002207 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002208 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002209
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002210 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002211 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2212 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2213 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002214 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002215
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002216 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2217 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2218 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2219
2220 if (Result.isInvalid())
2221 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2222
2223 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002224}
2225
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002226QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002227 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2228 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002229
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002230 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002231 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002232 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002233
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002234 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2235 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2236 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002237
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002238 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002239 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2240 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002241 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002242}
2243
2244
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002245
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002246Action::OwningExprResult
2247Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2248 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002249 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2250 switch (Kind) {
2251 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2252 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2253 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2254 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002255
Eli Friedmancfdd40c2009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002256 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002257}
2258
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002259Action::OwningExprResult
2260Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2261 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002262 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2263 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2264
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002265 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2266 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002267
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002268 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002269 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2270 Base.release();
2271 Idx.release();
2272 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2273 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2274 }
2275
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002276 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002277 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002278 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2279 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2280 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002281 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002282 }
2283
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002284 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2285}
2286
2287
2288Action::OwningExprResult
2289Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2290 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2291 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2292 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2293
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002294 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002295 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2296 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2297 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002298
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002299 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002300
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002301 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002302 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002303 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002304 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002305 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2306 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002307 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2308 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2309 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2310 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002311 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002312 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2313 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002314 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002315 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002316 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002317 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2318 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002319 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002320 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002321 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002322 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2323 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2324 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002325 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002326 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002327 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2328 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2329 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2330 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002331 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002332 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002333 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002334
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002335 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2336 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002337 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2338 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002339 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002340 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2341 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2342 // force the promotion here.
2343 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2344 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002345 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2346 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002347 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2348
2349 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2350 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002351 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002352 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2353 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2354 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2355 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002356 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2357 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002358 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2359
2360 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2361 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002362 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002363 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002364 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2365 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002366 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002367 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002368 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002369 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2370 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002371
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002372 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002373 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2374 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002375 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2376
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002377 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002378 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2379 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002380 // incomplete types are not object types.
2381 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2382 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2383 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2384 return ExprError();
2385 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002386
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002387 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002388 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002389 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2390 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002391 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002392
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002393 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002394 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002395 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2396 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2397 return ExprError();
2398 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002399
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002400 Base.release();
2401 Idx.release();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002402 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002403 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002404}
2405
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002406QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002407CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002408 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002409 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002410 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2411 // see FIXME there.
2412 //
2413 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2414 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002415 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002416
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002417 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002418 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002419
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002420 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002421 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2422 // to be selected.
2423 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002424
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002425 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2426 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002427 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002428
2429 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2430 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002431 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002432 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2433 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002434 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002435 do
2436 compStr++;
2437 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002438 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002439 do
2440 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002441 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002442 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002443
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002444 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002445 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2446 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002447 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramere8394df2010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002448 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002449 return QualType();
2450 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002451
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002452 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2453 // operates on.
2454 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002455 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002456
2457 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002458 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002459
2460 while (*compStr) {
2461 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2462 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2463 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2464 return QualType();
2465 }
2466 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002467 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002468
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002469 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002470 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002471 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002472 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002473 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002474 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002475 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002476 if (HexSwizzle)
2477 CompSize--;
2478
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002479 if (CompSize == 1)
2480 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002481
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002482 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002483 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002484 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2485 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2486 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2487 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002488 }
2489 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002490}
2491
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002492static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002493 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002494 const Selector &Sel,
2495 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002496
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002497 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002498 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002499 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002500 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002501
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002502 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2503 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002504 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002505 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002506 return D;
2507 }
2508 return 0;
2509}
2510
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002511static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002512 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002513 const Selector &Sel,
2514 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002515 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2516 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002517 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002518 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002519 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002520 GDecl = PD;
2521 break;
2522 }
2523 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002524 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002525 GDecl = OMD;
2526 break;
2527 }
2528 }
2529 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002530 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002531 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2532 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002533 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002534 if (GDecl)
2535 return GDecl;
2536 }
2537 }
2538 return GDecl;
2539}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002540
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002541Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002542Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2543 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002544 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2545 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002546 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002547 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2548 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2549
2550 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2551 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2552 //
2553 // T* t;
2554 // t.f;
2555 //
2556 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2557 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2558 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2559 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002560 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002561 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2562 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002563 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002564 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002565 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002566 return ExprError();
2567 }
2568 }
2569
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002570 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2571 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002572 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002573
2574 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2575 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002576 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002577 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2578 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2579 SS.getRange(),
2580 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002581 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002582}
2583
2584/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2585/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2586/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2587static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2588 Expr *BaseExpr,
2589 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002590 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002591 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002592 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2593 // diagnostics.
2594 if (!BaseExpr)
2595 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002596
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002597 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2598 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002599}
2600
2601// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2602// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2603// type. The restriction here is:
2604//
2605// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2606// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2607// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2608//
2609// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2610// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2611// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2612// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2613bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2614 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002615 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002616 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002617 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2618 if (!BaseRT) {
2619 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2620 // dependent.
2621 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2622 return false;
2623 }
2624 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002625
2626 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002627 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2628 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002629 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002630 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002631
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002632 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002633 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2634 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2635 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002636
Douglas Gregora9c3e822010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002637 if (!DC->isRecord())
2638 continue;
2639
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002640 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002641 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002642
2643 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2644 return false;
2645 }
2646
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002647 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002648 return true;
2649}
2650
2651static bool
2652LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2653 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002654 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2655 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002656 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2657 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002658 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002659 << BaseRange))
2660 return true;
2661
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002662 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2663 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2664 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2665
2666 bool MOUS;
2667 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2668 return false;
2669 }
2670
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002671 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2672 if (SS.isSet()) {
2673 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2674 // nested-name-specifier.
2675 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2676
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002677 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002678 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2679 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2680 return true;
2681 }
2682
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002683 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002684
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002685 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2686 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2687 << DC << SS.getRange();
2688 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002689 }
2690 }
2691
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002692 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2693 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002694
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002695 if (!R.empty())
2696 return false;
2697
2698 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2699 // for typos.
2700 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002701 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002702 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002703 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2704 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2705 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002706 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2707 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002708 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2709 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2710 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002711 return false;
2712 } else {
2713 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002714 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002715 }
2716
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002717 return false;
2718}
2719
2720Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002721Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002722 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002723 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002724 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002725 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002726 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2727 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2728
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002729 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2730 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002731 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002732 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2733 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002734 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002735
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002736 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002737
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002738 // Implicit member accesses.
2739 if (!Base) {
2740 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2741 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2742 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2743 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002744 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002745 return ExprError();
2746
2747 // Explicit member accesses.
2748 } else {
2749 OwningExprResult Result =
2750 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002751 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy(), TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002752
2753 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2754 Owned(Base);
2755 return ExprError();
2756 }
2757
2758 if (Result.get())
2759 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002760
2761 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2762 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002763 }
2764
Sebastian Redl0b4e3122010-05-07 09:09:23 +00002765 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002766 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2767 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002768}
2769
2770Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002771Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2772 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2773 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002774 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002775 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002776 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2777 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002778 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002779 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002780 if (IsArrow) {
2781 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2782 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2783 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002784 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002785
2786 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2787 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002788 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2789 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2790 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002791
2792 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002793 return ExprError();
2794
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002795 if (R.empty()) {
2796 // Rederive where we looked up.
2797 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2798 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2799 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002800
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002801 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002802 << MemberName << DC
2803 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002804 return ExprError();
2805 }
2806
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002807 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2808 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2809 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2810 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2811 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2812 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2813 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2814 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2815 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2816 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002817 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002818 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002819 return ExprError();
2820
2821 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2822 // result.
2823 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002824 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002825 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002826 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002827 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002828
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002829 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2830 // pick a member.
2831 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2832
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002833 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2834 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2835 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002836 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2837 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002838 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002839 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002840 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002841
2842 return Owned(MemExpr);
2843 }
2844
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002845 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002846 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002847 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2848
2849 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2850
2851 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2852 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2853 // error cases.
2854 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2855 return ExprError();
2856
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002857 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2858 if (!BaseExpr) {
2859 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002860 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002861 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002862
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002863 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2864 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2865 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2866 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002867 }
2868
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002869 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2870 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2871 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2872 // explicitly qualified.
2873 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2874 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2875 }
2876
2877 // Check the use of this member.
2878 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2879 Owned(BaseExpr);
2880 return ExprError();
2881 }
2882
2883 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2884 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2885 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002886 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2887 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002888 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2889 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2890
2891 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2892 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2893 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2894 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2895 else {
2896 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2897 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2898 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2899
2900 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2901 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2902
2903 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2904 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2905 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2906 }
2907
2908 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002909 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002910 return ExprError();
2911 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002912 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2913 MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002914 }
2915
2916 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2917 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2918 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002919 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002920 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2921 }
2922
2923 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2924 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2925 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002926 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002927 MemberFn->getType()));
2928 }
2929
2930 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2931 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2932 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002933 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2934 Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002935 }
2936
2937 Owned(BaseExpr);
2938
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002939 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002940 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002941 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002942 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2943 else
2944 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2945 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002946
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002947 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2948 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002949 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002950 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002951}
2952
2953/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2954/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2955/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2956/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2957/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2958/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2959/// an ordinary member expression.
2960///
2961/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2962/// fixed for ObjC++.
2963Sema::OwningExprResult
2964Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002965 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002966 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002967 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002968 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002969
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002970 // Perform default conversions.
2971 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002972
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002973 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002974 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2975
2976 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2977 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002978
2979 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002980 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002981 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2982 // call, and continue on.
2983 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2984 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2985 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2986 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2987 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002988 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2989 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002990 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2991 ->isRecordType()))) {
2992 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2993 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2994 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002995 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002996
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002997 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002998 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002999 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
Douglas Gregor143d3672010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003000 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003001 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003002 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003003
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003004 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3005 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3006 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3007 }
3008 }
3009 }
3010
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003011 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3012 // use that.
3013 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003014 if (IsArrow) {
3015 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3016 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3017 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003018 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003019 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003020 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3021 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003022 }
3023 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003024 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3025 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3026 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3027 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003028 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003029 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003030 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003031
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003032 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3033 // use that.
3034 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3035 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3036 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3037 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3038 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
3039 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
3040 }
3041 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003042
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003043 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003044
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003045 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003046 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003047 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3048 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3049 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3050 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3051 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3052 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3053 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3054 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3055 // Check the use of this method.
3056 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3057 return ExprError();
3058 }
3059 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3060 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3061 Selector SetterSel =
3062 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3063 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3064 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3065 if (!Setter) {
3066 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3067 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003068 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003069 }
3070 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3071 if (!Setter)
3072 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003073
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003074 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3075 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003076
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003077 if (Getter || Setter) {
3078 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003079
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003080 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003081 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003082 else
3083 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3084 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3085 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003086 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003087 PType,
3088 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3089 }
3090 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3091 << MemberName << BaseType);
3092 }
3093 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003094
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003095 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3096 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3097 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003098 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003099 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003100
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003101 if (IsArrow) {
3102 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003103 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003104 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3105 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003106 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3107 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3108 // struct MyRecord foo;
3109 // foo->bar
3110 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3111 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3112 // by now.
3113 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3114 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003115 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003116 IsArrow = false;
3117 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003118 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3119 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3120 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003121 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003122 } else {
3123 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3124 // type *foo;
3125 // foo.bar
3126 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3127 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3128 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3129 // the appropriate pointer type
3130 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3131 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3132 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3133 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3134 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003135 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003136 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3137 IsArrow = true;
3138 }
3139 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003140 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003141
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003142 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003143 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003144 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003145 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003146 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003147 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003148 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003149
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003150 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3151 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003152 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003153 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003154 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003155 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3156 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3157 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3158 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003159 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3160
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003161 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003162 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003163
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003164 if (!IV) {
3165 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3166 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3167 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003168 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003169 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003170 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003171 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3172 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003173 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3174 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003175 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003176 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003177 } else {
3178 Res.clear();
3179 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003180 }
3181 }
3182
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003183 if (IV) {
3184 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3185 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3186 // error cases.
3187 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3188 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003189
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003190 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3191 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3192 return ExprError();
3193 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3194 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3195 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3196 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3197 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3198 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3199 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3200 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3201 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3202 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3203 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3204 // AST for a function decl.
3205 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003206 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003207 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3208 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3209 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3210 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3211 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3212 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003213
3214 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3215 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003216 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003217 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003218 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003219 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3220 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003221 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003222 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003223 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003224
3225 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3226 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003227 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003228 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003229 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003230 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003231 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003232 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003233 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003234 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003235 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3236 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003237 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003238 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003239
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003240 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003241 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003242 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3243 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3244 // Check the use of this declaration
3245 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3246 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003247
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003248 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3249 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3250 }
3251 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3252 // Check the use of this method.
3253 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3254 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003255
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003256 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003257 OMD->getSendResultType(),
Douglas Gregor9a129192010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003258 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3259 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003260 }
3261 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003262
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003263 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003264 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003265 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003266
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003267 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3268 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003269 if (!IsArrow)
3270 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3271 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003272 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003273
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003274 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003275 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003276 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3277 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003278 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003279 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003280 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003281
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003282 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003283 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003284 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003285 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3286 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003287 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003288 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003289 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003290 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003291
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003292 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3293 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3294
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003295 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003296}
3297
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003298/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3299/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3300/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3301/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3302/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3303///
3304/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3305/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3306/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3307/// only be called
3308/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3309/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3310/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3311Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3312 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3313 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003314 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003315 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3316 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3317 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3318 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3319 return ExprError();
3320
3321 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3322
3323 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003324 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003325 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3326 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003327 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003328
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003329 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003330 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3331
3332 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3333 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3334 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3335
3336 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3337 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3338
3339 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3340 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003341 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3342 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003343 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003344 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3345 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003346 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003347 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003348 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003349 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3350 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003351
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003352 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3353 Owned(Base);
3354 return ExprError();
3355 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003356
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003357 if (Result.get()) {
3358 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3359 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3360 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3361 // call now.
3362 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3363 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003364 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), move(Result));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003365
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003366 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003367 }
3368
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003369 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003370 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3371 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003372 }
3373
3374 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003375}
3376
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003377Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3378 FunctionDecl *FD,
3379 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3380 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3381 Diag (CallLoc,
3382 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3383 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003384 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003385 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3386 } else {
3387 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3388 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3389
3390 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor8c702532010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003391 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3392 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003393
Douglas Gregor9961ce92010-07-08 18:37:38 +00003394 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3395 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3396 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3397 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003398
John McCall76d824f2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003399 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003400 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003401 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003402
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003403 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3404 InitializedEntity Entity
3405 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3406 InitializationKind Kind
3407 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3408 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3409 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3410
3411 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003412 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003413 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3414 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003415 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003416
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003417 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003418 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003419 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003420 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003421
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003422 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3423 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3424 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003425 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3426 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson714d0962009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003427 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3428 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003429 }
3430
3431 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003432 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003433}
3434
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003435/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3436/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3437/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3438/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3439/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3440/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003441bool
3442Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003443 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003444 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003445 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3446 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003447 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003448 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3449 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003450 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003451
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003452 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3453 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3454 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3455 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3456 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003457 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003458 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003459 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003460 }
3461
3462 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3463 // them.
3464 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3465 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3466 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3467 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003468 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003469 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003470 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3471 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3472 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003473 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003474 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003475 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003476 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003477 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003478 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003479 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3480 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3481 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3482 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3483 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003484 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003485 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003486 if (Invalid)
3487 return true;
3488 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3489 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3490 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003491
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003492 return false;
3493}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003494
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003495bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3496 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3497 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3498 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3499 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3500 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003501 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003502 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3503 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3504 bool Invalid = false;
3505 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3506 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3507 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3508 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003509 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003510 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003511 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003512
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003513 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003514 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3515 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003516
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003517 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3518 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003519 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003520 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003521 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003522
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003523 // Pass the argument
3524 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3525 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3526 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003527
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003528
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003529 InitializedEntity Entity =
3530 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3531 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3532 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3533 SourceLocation(),
3534 Owned(Arg));
3535 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3536 return true;
3537
3538 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003539 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003540 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003541
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003542 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003543 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003544 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3545 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003546
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003547 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003548 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003549 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003550 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003551
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003552 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003553 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003554 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003555 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003556 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003557 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003558 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003559 }
3560 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003561 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003562}
3563
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003564/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003565/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3566/// locations.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003567Action::OwningExprResult
3568Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3569 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003570 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003571 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003572
3573 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3574 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003575
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003576 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003577 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner38dbdb22007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003578 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003579
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003580 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003581 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3582 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3583 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3584 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3585 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003586 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003587 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3588 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003589
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003590 NumArgs = 0;
3591 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003592
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003593 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3594 RParenLoc));
3595 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003596
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003597 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003598 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003599 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3600 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003601 bool Dependent = false;
3602 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3603 Dependent = true;
3604 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3605 Dependent = true;
3606
3607 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003608 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003609 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3610
3611 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3612 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3613 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3614 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3615
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003616 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3617
3618 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3619 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3620 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3621 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3622 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3623 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3624 // method template.
3625 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003626 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3627 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003628 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003629
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003630 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3631 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003632 }
3633
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003634 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003635 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003636 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003637 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003638 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3639 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003640 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003641
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003642 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003643 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003644 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3645 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003646 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3647 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003648 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003649
3650 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3651 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003652 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3653 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003654
3655 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3656 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003657 TheCall.get(), 0))
3658 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003659
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003660 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003661 RParenLoc))
3662 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003663
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003664 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3665 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003666 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003667 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3668 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003669 }
3670 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003671 }
3672
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003673 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003674 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003675 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003676
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003677 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003678 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3679 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003680 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003681 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003682 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003683
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003684 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3685 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3686 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3687
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003688 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3689}
3690
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003691/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3692/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003693/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3694/// block-pointer type.
3695///
3696/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3697Sema::OwningExprResult
3698Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3699 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3700 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3701 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3702 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3703
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003704 // Promote the function operand.
3705 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3706
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003707 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3708 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003709 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3710 Args, NumArgs,
3711 Context.BoolTy,
3712 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003713
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003714 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3715 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3716 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3717 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003718 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003719 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003720 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3721 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003722 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003723 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003724 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003725 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003726 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003727 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003728 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3729 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3730
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003731 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003732 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003733 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3734 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003735 return ExprError();
3736
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003737 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003738 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003739
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003740 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003741 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003742 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003743 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003744 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003745 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003746
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003747 if (FDecl) {
3748 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3749 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3750 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis36ea3222010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003751 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003752 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003753 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003754 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3755 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3756 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3757 }
3758 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003759 }
3760
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003761 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003762 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3763 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3764 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003765 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3766 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003767 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3768 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003769 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003770 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003771 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003772 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003773
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003774 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3775 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003776 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3777 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003778
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003779 // Check for sentinels
3780 if (NDecl)
3781 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003782
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003783 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003784 if (FDecl) {
3785 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3786 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003787
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003788 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003789 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3790 } else if (NDecl) {
3791 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3792 return ExprError();
3793 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003794
Anders Carlssonf8984012009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003795 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003796}
3797
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003798Action::OwningExprResult
3799Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3800 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003801 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003802 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003803 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003804
3805 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3806 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3807 if (!TInfo)
3808 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3809
3810 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3811}
3812
3813Action::OwningExprResult
3814Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3815 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3816 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003817 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003818
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003819 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003820 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003821 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3822 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003823 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3824 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003825 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003826 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003827 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003828 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003829
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003830 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003831 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003832 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003833 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003834 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003835 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3836 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3837 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3838 &literalType);
3839 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003840 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003841 InitExpr.release();
3842 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003843
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003844 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003845 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003846 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003847 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003848 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003849
3850 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003851
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003852 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003853 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003854}
3855
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003856Action::OwningExprResult
3857Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003858 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3859 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3860 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003861
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003862 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003863 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003864
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003865 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3866 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003867 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003868 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003869}
3870
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003871static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3872 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003873 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003874 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3875
3876 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3877 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003878 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3879 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahanian2b9fc832009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003880 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003881 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3882 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3883 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003884
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003885 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3886 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3887 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3888 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3889 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3890 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3891 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3892 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003893
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003894 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3895 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3896 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3897 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3898 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3899 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003900
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003901 // FIXME: Assert here.
3902 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3903 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3904}
3905
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003906/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003907bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003908 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003909 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003910 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003911 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003912 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3913 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003914
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003915 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003916
3917 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3918 // type needs to be scalar.
3919 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3920 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003921 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3922 return false;
3923 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003924
Eli Friedmane98194d2010-07-17 20:43:49 +00003925 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
3926 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
3927 return true;
3928
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003929 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003930 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003931 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3932 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003933 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003934 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3935 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003936 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003937 return false;
3938 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003939
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003940 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003941 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003942 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003943 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003944 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003945 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003946 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003947 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003948 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3949 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3950 break;
3951 }
3952 }
3953 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3954 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3955 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003956 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003957 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003958 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003959
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003960 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3961 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3962 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3963 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003964
3965 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003966 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003967 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3968 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003969 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003970 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003971
3972 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003973 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003974
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003975 if (castType->isVectorType())
3976 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3977 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3978 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3979
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003980 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3981 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003982
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003983 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003984 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003985 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00003986 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003987 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3988 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3989 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3990 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003991 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003992 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3993 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3994 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003995 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003996
3997 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003998 return false;
3999}
4000
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004001bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
4002 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004003 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004004
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004005 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004006 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004007 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004008 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004009 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004010 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004011 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004012 } else
4013 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004014 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004015 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004016
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004017 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004018 return false;
4019}
4020
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004021bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004022 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004023 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004024
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004025 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004026
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004027 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4028 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004029 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4030 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4031 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4032 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004033 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004034 return false;
4035 }
4036
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004037 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004038 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4039 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004040 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4041 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4042 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4043 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004044
4045 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4046 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4047 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004048
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004049 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004050 return false;
4051}
4052
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004053Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004054Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004055 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4056 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
4057 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004058
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004059 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4060 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4061 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004062 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004063
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004064 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004065 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004066 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004067 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
4068 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004069
4070 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
4071}
4072
4073Action::OwningExprResult
4074Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
4075 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4076 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
4077
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004078 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004079 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004080 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004081 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004082 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004083
Douglas Gregorb33eed02010-04-16 22:09:46 +00004084 Op.release();
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004085 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004086 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004087 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4088 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004089}
4090
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004091/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4092/// of comma binary operators.
4093Action::OwningExprResult
4094Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4095 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4096 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4097 if (!E)
4098 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004099
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004100 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004101
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004102 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4103 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4104 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004105
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004106 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4107}
4108
4109Action::OwningExprResult
4110Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4111 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004112 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004113 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004114 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004115 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004116
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004117 // Check for an altivec literal,
4118 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004119 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4120 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4121 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4122 return ExprError();
4123 }
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004124 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4125 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4126 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4127 }
4128 else
4129 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4130 }
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004131
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004132 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4133 // then handle it as such.
4134 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004135 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4136 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4137 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4138
4139 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4140 // braces instead of the original commas.
4141 Op.release();
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004142 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4143 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004144 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4145 E->setType(Ty);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004146 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004147 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004148 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004149 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4150 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004151 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004152 }
4153}
4154
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004155Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004156 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004157 MultiExprArg Val,
4158 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004159 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4160 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004161 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4162 Expr *expr;
4163 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4164 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4165 else
4166 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004167 return Owned(expr);
4168}
4169
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004170/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4171/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004172/// C99 6.5.15
4173QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4174 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004175 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4176 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4177 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4178
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004179 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4180 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4181 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4182 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4183 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4184 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004185
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004186 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004187 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4188 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4189 << CondTy;
4190 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004191 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004192
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004193 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004194 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4195 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004196
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004197 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4198 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004199 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4200 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4201 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004202 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004203
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004204 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4205 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004206 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4207 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004208 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004209 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004210 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004211 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004212 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004213 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004214
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004215 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004216 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004217 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4218 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4219 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4220 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4221 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4222 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4223 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004224 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4225 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004226 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004227 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004228 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4229 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004230 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004231 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004232 // promote the null to a pointer.
4233 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004234 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004235 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004236 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004237 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004238 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004239 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004240 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004241
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004242 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4243 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4244 QuestionLoc);
4245 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4246 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004247
4248
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004249 // Handle block pointer types.
4250 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4251 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4252 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4253 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004254 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4255 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004256 return destType;
4257 }
4258 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004259 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004260 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004261 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004262 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4263 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4264 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004265 return LHSTy;
4266 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004267 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004268 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4269 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004270
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004271 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4272 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004273 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004274 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004275 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4276 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4277 // to get a consistent AST.
4278 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004279 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4280 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004281 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004282 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004283 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004284 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4285 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004286 return LHSTy;
4287 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004288
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004289 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4290 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4291 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004292 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4293 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004294
4295 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4296 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4297 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004298 QualType destPointee
4299 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004300 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004301 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4302 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4303 // Promote to void*.
4304 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004305 return destType;
4306 }
4307 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004308 QualType destPointee
4309 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004310 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004311 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004312 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004313 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004314 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004315 return destType;
4316 }
4317
4318 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4319 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4320 return LHSTy;
4321 }
4322 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4323 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4324 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4325 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4326 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4327 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4328 // to get a consistent AST.
4329 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004330 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4331 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004332 return incompatTy;
4333 }
4334 // The pointer types are compatible.
4335 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4336 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4337 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4338 // type.
4339 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4340 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004341 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4342 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004343 return LHSTy;
4344 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004345
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004346 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4347 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4348 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4349 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004350 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004351 return RHSTy;
4352 }
4353 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4354 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4355 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004356 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004357 return LHSTy;
4358 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004359
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004360 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004361 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4362 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004363 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004364}
4365
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004366/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4367/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4368QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4369 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4370 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4371 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004372
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004373 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4374 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4375 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4376 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4377 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4378 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4379 return LHSTy;
4380 }
4381 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4382 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4383 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4384 return RHSTy;
4385 }
4386 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4387 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4388 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4389 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4390 return LHSTy;
4391 }
4392 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4393 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4394 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4395 return RHSTy;
4396 }
4397 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4398 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4399 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4400 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4401 return LHSTy;
4402 }
4403 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4404 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4405 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4406 return RHSTy;
4407 }
4408 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4409 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004410
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004411 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4412 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4413 return LHSTy;
4414 }
4415 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4416 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4417 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004418
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004419 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4420 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4421 // type. This allows
4422 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4423 // where B is a subclass of A.
4424 //
4425 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4426 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4427 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4428 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004429
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004430 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4431 // It could return the composite type.
4432 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4433 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4434 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4435 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4436 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4437 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4438 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4439 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4440 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4441 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4442 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4443 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4444 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4445 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004446 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004447 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4448 ;
4449 else {
4450 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4451 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4452 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4453 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4454 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4455 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4456 return incompatTy;
4457 }
4458 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4459 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4460 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4461 return compositeType;
4462 }
4463 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4464 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4465 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4466 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4467 QualType destPointee
4468 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4469 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4470 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4471 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4472 // Promote to void*.
4473 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4474 return destType;
4475 }
4476 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4477 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4478 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4479 QualType destPointee
4480 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4481 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4482 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4483 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4484 // Promote to void*.
4485 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4486 return destType;
4487 }
4488 return QualType();
4489}
4490
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004491/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004492/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004493Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4494 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4495 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4496 ExprArg RHS) {
4497 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4498 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004499
4500 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4501 // was the condition.
4502 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4503 if (isLHSNull)
4504 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004505
4506 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004507 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004508 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004509 return ExprError();
4510
4511 Cond.release();
4512 LHS.release();
4513 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004514 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004515 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004516 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004517}
4518
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004519// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004520// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004521// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4522// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4523// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004524Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004525Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004526 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004527
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004528 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4529 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4530 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4531 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4532 return Compatible;
4533 }
4534
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004535 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004536 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4537 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004538
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004539 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004540 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4541 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004542
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004543 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004544
4545 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4546 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4547 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004548 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004549 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004550 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004551
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004552 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4553 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004554 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004555 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004556 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004557 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004558
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004559 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004560 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4561 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004562 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004563
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004564 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004565 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004566 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004567
4568 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004569 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4570 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004571 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004572 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004573 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004574 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4575 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4576 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4577 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4578 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4579 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004580 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004581 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004582 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004583 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004584
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004585 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004586 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004587 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004588 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004589
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004590 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4591 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4592 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4593 // warning can be disabled.
4594 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4595 return ConvTy;
4596 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4597 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004598
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004599 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4600 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4601 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4602 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4603 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4604 do {
4605 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4606 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004607
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004608 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4609 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4610 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004611
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004612 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004613 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004614 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004615
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004616 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004617 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004618 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004619 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004620}
4621
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004622/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4623/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4624/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4625// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004626Sema::AssignConvertType
4627Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004628 QualType rhsType) {
4629 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004630
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004631 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004632 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4633 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004634
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004635 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4636 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4637 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004638
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004639 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004640
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004641 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004642 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004643 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004644
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004645 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4646 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4647 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4648 }
4649 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004650 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004651 return ConvTy;
4652}
4653
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004654/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4655/// for assignment compatibility.
4656Sema::AssignConvertType
4657Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004658 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4659 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004660 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4661 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004662 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004663 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004664 }
4665 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4666 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004667 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4668 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004669 return IncompatiblePointer;
4670 return Compatible;
4671 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004672 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004673 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004674 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004675 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4676 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4677 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4678 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4679 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4680 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004681
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004682 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4683 return Compatible;
4684 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4685 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004686 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004687}
4688
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004689/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4690/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004691/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4692///
4693/// int a, *pint;
4694/// short *pshort;
4695/// struct foo *pfoo;
4696///
4697/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4698/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4699/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4700/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4701///
4702/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004703/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004704///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004705Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004706Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004707 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4708 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004709 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4710 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004711
4712 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004713 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004714
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004715 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4716 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4717 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4718 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4719 return Compatible;
4720 }
4721
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004722 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4723 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4724 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4725 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4726 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4727 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4728 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004729 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004730 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004731 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004732 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004733 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004734 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4735 // to the same ExtVector type.
4736 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4737 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4738 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004739 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004740 return Compatible;
4741 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004742
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004743 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004744 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4745 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4746 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4747 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4748 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4749 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004750 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004751
4752 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4753 // vector type and vice versa
4754 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4755 return Compatible;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004756 }
4757 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004758 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004759
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004760 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4761 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004762 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004763
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004764 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004765 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004766 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004767
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004768 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004769 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004770
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004771 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004772 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004773 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4774 return Compatible;
4775 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004776 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004777 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4778 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004779 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004780
4781 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004782 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004783 return Compatible;
4784 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004785 return Incompatible;
4786 }
4787
4788 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4789 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004790 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004791
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004792 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004793 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004794 return Compatible;
4795
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004796 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4797 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004798
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004799 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004800 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004801 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004802 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004803 return Incompatible;
4804 }
4805
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004806 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4807 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4808 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004809
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004810 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004811 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004812 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4813 return Compatible;
4814 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004815 }
4816 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004817 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004818 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004819 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004820 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4821 return Compatible;
4822 }
4823 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4824 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4825 return Compatible;
4826 return Incompatible;
4827 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004828 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004829 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004830 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4831 return Compatible;
4832
4833 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004834 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004835
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004836 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004837 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004838
4839 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004840 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004841 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004842 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004843 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004844 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4845 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4846 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4847 return Compatible;
4848
4849 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4850 return PointerToInt;
4851
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004852 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004853 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004854 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4855 return Compatible;
4856 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004857 }
4858 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004859 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004860 return Compatible;
4861 return Incompatible;
4862 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004863
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004864 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004865 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004866 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004867 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004868 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004869}
4870
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004871/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4872/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004873static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004874 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4875 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4876 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004877 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004878 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004879 SourceLocation());
4880 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4881 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4882
4883 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4884 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004885 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004886 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004887 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004888}
4889
4890Sema::AssignConvertType
4891Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4892 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4893
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004894 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004895 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4896 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004897 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004898 return Incompatible;
4899
4900 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4901 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4902 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4903 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004904 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4905 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004906 it != itend; ++it) {
4907 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4908 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4909 // 1) void pointer
4910 // 2) null pointer constant
4911 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004912 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004913 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004914 InitField = *it;
4915 break;
4916 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004917
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004918 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004919 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004920 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004921 InitField = *it;
4922 break;
4923 }
4924 }
4925
4926 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4927 == Compatible) {
4928 InitField = *it;
4929 break;
4930 }
4931 }
4932
4933 if (!InitField)
4934 return Incompatible;
4935
4936 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4937 return Compatible;
4938}
4939
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004940Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004941Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004942 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4943 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4944 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4945 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4946 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004947 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004948 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004949 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004950 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004951 }
4952
4953 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4954 // structures.
4955 }
4956
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004957 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4958 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004959 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4960 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004961 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004962 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004963 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004964 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004965 return Compatible;
4966 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004967
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004968 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004969 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004970 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyef7c0ff2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00004971 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004972 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004973 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004974 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004975 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004976
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004977 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4978 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004979
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004980 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4981 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004982 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4983 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4984 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4985 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004986 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004987 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004988 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004989 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004990}
4991
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004992QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004993 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004994 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004995 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004996 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00004997}
4998
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004999QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005000 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005001 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005002 QualType lhsType =
5003 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5004 QualType rhsType =
5005 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005006
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005007 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005008 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005009 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005010
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005011 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5012 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005013 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
5014 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005015 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5016 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005017 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005018 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005019 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5020 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5021 return lhsType;
5022 }
5023
5024 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5025 return rhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005026 }
5027 }
5028 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005029
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005030 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5031 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5032 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
5033 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5034 return rhsType;
5035 }
5036
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005037 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5038 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5039 bool swapped = false;
5040 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5041 swapped = true;
5042 std::swap(rex, lex);
5043 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5044 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005045
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005046 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005047 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005048 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005049 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005050 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005051 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005052 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5053 return lhsType;
5054 }
5055 }
5056 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5057 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5058 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005059 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005060 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5061 return lhsType;
5062 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005063 }
5064 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005065
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005066 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005067 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005068 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005069 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005070 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005071}
5072
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005073QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5074 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005075 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005076 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005077
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005078 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005079
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005080 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5081 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5082 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005083
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005084 // Check for division by zero.
5085 if (isDiv &&
5086 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005087 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005088 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005089
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005090 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005091}
5092
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005093QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005094 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005095 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005096 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5097 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005098 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5099 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5100 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005101
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005102 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005103
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005104 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5105 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005106
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005107 // Check for remainder by zero.
5108 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005109 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5110 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005111
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005112 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005113}
5114
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005115QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005116 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005117 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5118 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5119 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5120 return compType;
5121 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005122
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005123 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005124
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005125 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005126 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5127 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5128 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005129 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005130 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005131
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005132 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5133 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005134 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005135 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5136
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005137 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005138
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005139 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005140 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005141
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005142 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5143 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005144 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5145 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005146 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005147 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005148 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005149
5150 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5151 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5152 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005153 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005154 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5155 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5156 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5157 return QualType();
5158 }
5159
5160 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5161 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5162 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005163 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005164 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005165 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005166 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005167 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5168 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005169 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5170 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005171 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005172 return QualType();
5173 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005174 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005175 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005176 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5177 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5178 return QualType();
5179 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005180
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005181 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005182 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5183 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5184 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5185 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5186 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005187 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005188 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5189 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005190 return PExp->getType();
5191 }
5192 }
5193
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005194 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005195}
5196
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005197// C99 6.5.6
5198QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005199 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5200 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5201 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5202 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5203 return compType;
5204 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005205
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005206 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005207
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005208 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005209
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005210 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005211 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5212 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005213 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005214 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005215 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005216
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005217 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005218 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005219 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005220
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005221 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005222
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005223 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5224 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5225 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5226 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5227 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5228 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5229 return QualType();
5230 }
5231
5232 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5233 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5234 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5235 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5236 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005237 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005238 return QualType();
5239 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005240
5241 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5242 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5243 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005244 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005245 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005246 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005247 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005248 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005249
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005250 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005251 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005252 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5253 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5254 return QualType();
5255 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005256
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005257 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005258 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5259 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5260 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5261 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5262 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5263 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005264 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005265 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5266
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005267 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005268 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005269 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005270
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005271 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005272 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005273 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005274
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005275 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5276 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5277 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5278 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5279 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5280 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5281 return QualType();
5282 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005283
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005284 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5285 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5286 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5287 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005288 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005289 return QualType();
5290 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005291
5292 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5293 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5294 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5295 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5296 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005297 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5298 << rex->getSourceRange()
5299 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005300 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005301
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005302 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5303 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5304 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5305 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5306 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5307 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5308 return QualType();
5309 }
5310 } else {
5311 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5312 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5313 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5314 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5315 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5316 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5317 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5318 return QualType();
5319 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005320 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005321
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005322 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5323 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5324 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5325 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5326 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005327 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005328 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005329
5330 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005331 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5332 }
5333 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005334
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005335 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005336}
5337
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005338// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005339QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005340 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005341 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005342 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5343 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005344 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005345
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005346 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5347 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5348 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5349
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005350 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5351 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005352 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5353 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5354 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5355 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5356 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005357 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005358 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005359 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005360
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005361 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005362
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005363 // Sanity-check shift operands
5364 llvm::APSInt Right;
5365 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005366 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5367 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005368 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005369 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5370 else {
5371 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5372 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5373 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5374 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5375 }
5376 }
5377
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005378 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005379 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005380}
5381
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005382static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5383 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5384 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5385 return true;
5386 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5387 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5388 }
5389 return false;
5390}
5391
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005392// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005393QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005394 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5395 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5396
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005397 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005398 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005399 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005400
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005401 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5402 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005403
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005404 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
5405 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005406 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5407 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5408 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005409 //
5410 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5411 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5412 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5413 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5414 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5415 // result.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005416 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5417 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005418 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005419 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005420 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() && !Loc.isMacroID() &&
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005421 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005422 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5423 << 0 // self-
5424 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::EQ
5425 || Opc == BinaryOperator::LE
5426 || Opc == BinaryOperator::GE));
5427 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5428 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5429 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5430 // what is it always going to eval to?
5431 char always_evals_to;
5432 switch(Opc) {
5433 case BinaryOperator::EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
5434 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5435 break;
5436 case BinaryOperator::NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
5437 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5438 break;
5439 default:
5440 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5441 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5442 break;
5443 }
5444 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5445 << 1 // array
5446 << always_evals_to);
5447 }
5448 }
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005449 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005450
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005451 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5452 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5453 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5454 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005455
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005456 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5457 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005458 Expr *literalString = 0;
5459 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005460 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005461 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005462 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005463 literalString = lex;
5464 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005465 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5466 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005467 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005468 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005469 literalString = rex;
5470 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5471 }
5472
5473 if (literalString) {
5474 std::string resultComparison;
5475 switch (Opc) {
5476 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5477 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5478 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5479 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5480 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5481 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5482 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5483 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005484
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005485 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5486 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5487 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005488 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005489 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005490 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005491
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005492 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5493 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5494 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5495 else {
5496 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5497 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5498 }
5499
5500 lType = lex->getType();
5501 rType = rex->getType();
5502
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005503 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005504 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005505
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005506 if (isRelational) {
5507 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005508 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005509 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005510 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005511 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005512 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005513
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005514 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005515 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005516 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005517
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005518 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005519 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005520 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005521 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005522
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005523 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5524 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005525 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005526 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005527 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005528 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005529 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005530
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005531 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005532 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5533 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005534 if (!isRelational &&
5535 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5536 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5537 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005538 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5539 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005540 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5541 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005542 Diag(Loc,
5543 isSFINAEContext()?
5544 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5545 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005546 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005547
5548 if (isSFINAEContext())
5549 return QualType();
5550
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005551 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5552 return ResultTy;
5553 }
5554 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005555 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5556 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5557 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5558 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5559 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5560 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005561 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005562 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005563 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005564 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005565 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005566 if (T.isNull()) {
5567 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5568 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5569 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005570 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005571 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005572 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005573 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005574 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005575 }
5576
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005577 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5578 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005579 return ResultTy;
5580 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005581 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5582 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5583 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5584 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5585 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5586 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5587 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5588 }
5589 } else if (!isRelational &&
5590 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5591 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5592 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5593 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5594 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5595 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5596 }
5597 } else {
5598 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005599 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005600 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005601 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005602 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005603 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005604 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005605 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005606
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005607 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005608 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005609 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005610 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005611 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5612 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005613 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5614 lType->isMemberPointerType()
5615 ? CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer
5616 : CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005617 return ResultTy;
5618 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005619 if (LHSIsNull &&
5620 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5621 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005622 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5623 rType->isMemberPointerType()
5624 ? CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer
5625 : CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005626 return ResultTy;
5627 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005628
5629 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005630 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005631 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5632 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005633 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5634 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5635 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5636 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5637 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5638 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5639 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5640 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005641 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005642 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005643 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005644 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005645 if (T.isNull()) {
5646 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005647 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005648 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005649 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005650 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005651 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005652 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005653 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005654 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005655
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005656 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5657 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005658 return ResultTy;
5659 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005660
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005661 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005662 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5663 return ResultTy;
5664 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005665
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005666 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005667 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005668 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5669 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005670
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005671 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005672 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005673 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005674 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005675 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005676 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005677 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005678 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005679 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005680 if (!isRelational
5681 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5682 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005683 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005684 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005685 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005686 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005687 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5688 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5689 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005690 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005691 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005692 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005693 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005694
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005695 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005696 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005697 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5698 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005699 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005700 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005701 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005702 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005703
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005704 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5705 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005706 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005707 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005708 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005709 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005710 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005711 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005712 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005713 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005714 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5715 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005716 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005717 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005718 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005719 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005720 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5721 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005722 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005723 bool isError = false;
5724 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5725 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5726 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005727 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005728 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005729 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005730 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5731 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5732 isError = true;
5733 } else
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005734 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005735
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005736 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005737 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005738 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005739 if (isError)
5740 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005741 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005742
5743 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5744 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005745 else
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005746 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005747 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005748 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005749
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005750 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005751 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5752 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005753 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005754 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005755 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005756 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5757 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005758 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005759 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005760 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005761 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005762}
5763
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005764/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005765/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005766/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5767/// types.
5768QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005769 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005770 bool isRelational) {
5771 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5772 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005773 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005774 if (vType.isNull())
5775 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005776
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005777 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5778 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005779
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005780 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5781 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5782 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005783 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005784 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5785 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5786 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005787 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5788 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5789 << 0 // self-
5790 << 2 // "a constant"
5791 );
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005792 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005793
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005794 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005795 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5796 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005797 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005798 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005799
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005800 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5801 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5802 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005803 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005804 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005805
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005806 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005807 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005808 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005809 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005810 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005811 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5812
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005813 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005814 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005815 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5816}
5817
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005818inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005819 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005820 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5821 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5822 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5823 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5824
5825 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5826 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005827
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005828 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005829
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005830 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005831 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005832 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005833}
5834
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005835inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005836 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5837
5838 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5839 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5840 // is a constant.
5841 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman6b197e02010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005842 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattnerdeee7a32010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005843 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005844 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5845 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5846 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5847 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5848 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5849 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5850 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5851 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5852 << rex->getSourceRange()
5853 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5854 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::LAnd ? "&" : "|");
5855 }
5856 }
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005857
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005858 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5859 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5860 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005861
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005862 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5863 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005864
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005865 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005866 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005867
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005868 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5869 // non-overloadable operands.
5870
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005871 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5872 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005873 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5874 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5875 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005876 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005877
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005878 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5879 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5880 // The result is a bool.
5881 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005882}
5883
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005884/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5885/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5886/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5887///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005888static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005889 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5890 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5891 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5892 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005893 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005894 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5895 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5896 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5897 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005898 }
5899 }
5900 return false;
5901}
5902
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005903/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5904/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5905static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005906 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005907 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005908 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005909 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5910 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005911 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5912 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005913
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005914 unsigned Diag = 0;
5915 bool NeedType = false;
5916 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005917 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005918 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005919 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5920 NeedType = true;
5921 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005922 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005923 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5924 NeedType = true;
5925 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005926 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005927 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5928 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005929 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5930 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005931 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005932 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5933 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005934 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5935 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005936 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5937 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005938 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005939 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005940 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005941 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005942 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5943 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005944 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005945 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5946 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005947 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5948 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5949 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005950 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5951 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5952 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005953 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5954 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5955 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005956 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005957
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005958 SourceRange Assign;
5959 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5960 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005961 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005962 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005963 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005964 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005965 return true;
5966}
5967
5968
5969
5970// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005971QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5972 SourceLocation Loc,
5973 QualType CompoundType) {
5974 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5975 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005976 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005977
5978 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5979 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005980 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005981 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005982 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005983 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005984 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
5985 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
5986 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
5987 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
5988 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
5989 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
5990 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
5991 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
5992 }
5993 }
5994
5995 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005996 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5997 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5998 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005999 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006000 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006001 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006002 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006003
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006004 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6005 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6006 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006007 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006008 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6009 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6010 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
6011 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
6012 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006013 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006014 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006015 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6016 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6017 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006018 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6019 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006020 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
6021 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
6022 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006023 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006024 }
6025 } else {
6026 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006027 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006028 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006029
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006030 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006031 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006032 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006033
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006034
6035 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6036 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6037 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6038 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6039 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6040 // check.
6041 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
6042 if (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref &&
6043 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6044 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6045 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6046 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6047 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6048 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6049 }
6050
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006051 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6052 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006053 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006054 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6055 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006056 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006057 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006058 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006059}
6060
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006061// C99 6.5.17
6062QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis639ffb02010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006063 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6064
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00006065 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006066 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6067 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6068 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006069
6070 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
6071 // incomplete in C++).
6072
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006073 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00006074}
6075
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006076/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6077/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006078QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006079 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006080 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6081 return Context.DependentTy;
6082
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006083 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6084 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00006085
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006086 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6087 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6088 if (!isInc) {
6089 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6090 return QualType();
6091 }
6092 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6093 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6094 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006095 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006096 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6097 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006098
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006099 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006100 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006101 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6102 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6103 << Op->getSourceRange();
6104 return QualType();
6105 }
6106
6107 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006108 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006109 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006110 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6111 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6112 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6113 return QualType();
6114 }
6115
6116 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006117 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006118 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006119 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006120 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006121 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006122 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006123 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006124 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006125 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6126 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6127 return QualType();
6128 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006129 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006130 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6131 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006132 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006133 } else {
6134 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006135 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006136 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00006137 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006138 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006139 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006140 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006141 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006142 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6143 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6144 // operand.
6145 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6146 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006147}
6148
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006149/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006150/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006151/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6152/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6153/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6154/// - &(x) => x
6155/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6156/// - &s.xx => s
6157/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6158/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6159/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6160/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006161static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006162 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006163 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006164 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006165 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006166 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6167 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6168 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006169 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006170 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006171 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006172 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006173 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006174 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6175 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006176 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6177 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6178 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6179 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6180 }
6181 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006182 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006183 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6184 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006185
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006186 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006187 case UnaryOperator::Real:
6188 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
6189 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
6190 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6191 default:
6192 return 0;
6193 }
6194 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006195 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006196 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006197 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006198 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6199 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006200 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006201 default:
6202 return 0;
6203 }
6204}
6205
6206/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006207/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006208/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006209/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006210/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006211/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006212/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006213QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006214 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6215 op = op->IgnoreParens();
6216
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006217 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6218 return Context.DependentTy;
6219
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006220 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6221 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6222 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6223 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6224 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6225 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6226 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6227 }
6228 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6229 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6230 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006231 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006232 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006233
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006234 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6235 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6236 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6237 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6238 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6239 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6240 // branch of the if, below.
6241 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6242 << dcl;
6243 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6244
6245 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6246 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6247 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6248 .getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006249 }
6250
6251 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006252 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6253 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6254 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6255 if (isSFINAEContext())
6256 return QualType();
Chris Lattner93b28362010-07-05 19:36:34 +00006257 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op))
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006258 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Chris Lattner93b28362010-07-05 19:36:34 +00006259 else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006260 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006261 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006262 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006263 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006264 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6265 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006266 return QualType();
6267 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006268 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006269 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6270 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6271 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006272 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006273 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006274 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006275 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006276 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006277 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006278 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6279 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6280 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6281 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6282 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006283 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6284 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006285 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6286 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006287 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6288 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006289 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006290 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006291 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6292 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006293 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006294 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6295 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006296 return QualType();
6297 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006298 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006299 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006300 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006301 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006302 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6303 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006304 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006305 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006306 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6307 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006308 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006309 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6310 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6311 return QualType();
6312 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006313
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006314 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6315 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006316 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006317 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006318 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes5773a1b2008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006319 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006320 // As above.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006321 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6322 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006323 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6324 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6325 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006326 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006327 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006328
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006329 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6330 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6331 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6332 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6333 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6334 }
6335
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006336 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor0bdcb8a2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006337 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6338 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006339 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006340}
6341
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006342/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006343QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006344 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6345 return Context.DependentTy;
6346
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006347 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006348 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6349 QualType Result;
6350
6351 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6352 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6353 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6354 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6355 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6356 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6357 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6358 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6359 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006360
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006361 if (Result.isNull()) {
6362 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6363 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6364 return QualType();
6365 }
6366
6367 return Result;
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006368}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006369
6370static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6371 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6372 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6373 switch (Kind) {
6374 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006375 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6376 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006377 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6378 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6379 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6380 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6381 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6382 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6383 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6384 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6385 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6386 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6387 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6388 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6389 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6390 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6391 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6392 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6393 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6394 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6395 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6396 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6397 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6398 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6399 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6400 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6401 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6402 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6403 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6404 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6405 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6406 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6407 }
6408 return Opc;
6409}
6410
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006411static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6412 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6413 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6414 switch (Kind) {
6415 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6416 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6417 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6418 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6419 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6420 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6421 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6422 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6423 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006424 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6425 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
Chris Lattnerd0f76512007-06-08 22:16:53 +00006426 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006427 }
6428 return Opc;
6429}
6430
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006431/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6432/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6433/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006434Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6435 unsigned Op,
6436 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006437 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006438 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006439 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6440 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6441 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006442
6443 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006444 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6445 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6446 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006447 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6448 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6449 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6450 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6451 break;
6452 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006453 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006454 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6455 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006456 break;
6457 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6458 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6459 break;
6460 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6461 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6462 break;
6463 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6464 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6465 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006466 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006467 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6468 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6469 break;
6470 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6471 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6472 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6473 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006474 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006475 break;
6476 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6477 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006478 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006479 break;
6480 case BinaryOperator::And:
6481 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6482 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6483 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6484 break;
6485 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6486 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006487 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006488 break;
6489 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6490 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006491 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6492 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006493 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6494 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6495 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006496 break;
6497 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006498 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6499 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6500 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6501 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006502 break;
6503 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006504 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6505 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6506 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006507 break;
6508 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006509 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6510 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6511 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006512 break;
6513 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6514 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006515 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6516 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6517 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6518 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006519 break;
6520 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6521 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6522 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006523 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6524 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6525 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6526 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006527 break;
6528 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6529 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6530 break;
6531 }
6532 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006533 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006534 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006535 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6536 else
6537 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006538 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6539 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006540}
6541
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006542/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6543/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006544static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6545 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006546 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6547 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6548 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006549 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006550 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6551
6552 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6553 return;
6554
6555 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6556 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6557 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006558 return;
6559 }
6560
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006561 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6562 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006563 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006564
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006565 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006566 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006567
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006568 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6569 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6570 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6571 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006572 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006573 return;
6574 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006575
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006576 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006577 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6578 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006579}
6580
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006581/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6582/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6583/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6584/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006585static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6586 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006587 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6588 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6589 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6590 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006591 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006592 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006593 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6594
6595 // Subs are not binary operators.
6596 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6597 return;
6598
6599 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6600 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006601 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6602 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006603 return;
6604
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006605 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006606 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006607 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006608 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6609 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006610 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006611 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006612 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6613 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6614 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6615 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006616 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006617 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006618 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006619 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6620 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006621 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006622 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006623 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6624 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6625 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6626 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006627}
6628
6629/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6630/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6631/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6632static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6633 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006634 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006635 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6636}
6637
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006638// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006639Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6640 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6641 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006642 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006643 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006644
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006645 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6646 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006647
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006648 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6649 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6650
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006651 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6652}
6653
6654Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6655 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6656 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006657 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006658 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006659 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6660 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6661 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6662 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6663 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006664 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006665 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006666 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6667 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6668 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006669
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006670 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6671 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006672 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006673 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006674
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006675 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006676 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006677}
6678
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006679Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006680 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006681 ExprArg InputArg) {
6682 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006683
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006684 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006685 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006686 QualType resultType;
6687 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006688 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6689 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6690 break;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006691
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006692 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6693 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006694 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6695 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006696 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006697 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006698 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6699 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6700 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006701 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006702 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006703 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006704 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006705 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006706 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006707 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006708 break;
6709 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6710 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006711 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6712 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006713 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6714 break;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006715 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6716 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006717 break;
6718 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6719 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6720 break;
6721 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6722 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6723 resultType->isPointerType())
6724 break;
6725
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006726 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6727 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006728 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006729 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6730 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006731 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6732 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006733 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6734 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6735 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006736 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006737 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006738 else if (!resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006739 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6740 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006741 break;
6742 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006743 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006744 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006745 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006746 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6747 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006748 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006749 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6750 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006751 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006752 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6753 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006754 break;
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006755 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006756 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006757 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006758 break;
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006759 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006760 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006761 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006762 }
6763 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006764 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006765
6766 InputArg.release();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006767 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006768}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006769
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006770Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6771 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6772 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006773 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006774 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6775 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006776 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6777 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6778 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6779 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006780 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006781 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006782 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6783 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6784 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006785
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006786 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6787 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006788
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006789 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6790}
6791
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006792// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6793Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6794 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6795 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6796}
6797
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006798/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006799Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6800 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6801 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006802 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattner3318e862009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006803 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006804
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006805 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6806 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006807 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006808 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006809
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006810 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006811 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6812 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006813}
6814
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006815Sema::OwningExprResult
6816Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6817 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6818 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006819 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6820 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6821
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006822 bool isFileScope
6823 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006824 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006825 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006826
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006827 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6828 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6829 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006830
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006831 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6832 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6833 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006834
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006835 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6836 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6837 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6838 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6839 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006840
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006841 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006842 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006843 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006844
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006845 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6846 // expressions are not lvalues.
6847
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006848 substmt.release();
6849 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006850}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006851
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006852Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6853 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006854 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6855 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006856 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6857 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006858 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006859 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006860
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006861 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6862 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6863 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006864 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006865 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6866 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6867
6868 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6869 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6870 if (!Dependent
6871 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6872 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6873 << TypeRange))
6874 return ExprError();
6875
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006876 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6877 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006878 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6879 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006880 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006881 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6882 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006883
6884 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6885 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6886 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6887 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6888 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6889 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6890 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6891 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6892 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6893 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6894 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6895 if(!AT)
6896 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6897 << CurrentType);
6898 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6899 } else
6900 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6901
6902 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6903 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6904 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6905 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6906 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6907 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6908 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6909 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6910
6911 // Record this array index.
6912 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6913 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6914 continue;
6915 }
6916
6917 // Offset of a field.
6918 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6919 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6920 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6921 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6922 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6923 continue;
6924 }
6925
6926 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6927 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6928 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6929 return ExprError();
6930
6931 // Look for the designated field.
6932 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6933 if (!RC)
6934 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6935 << CurrentType);
6936 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6937
6938 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6939 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6940 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6941 // (clause 9).
6942 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6943 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6944 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6945 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6946 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6947 << CurrentType))
6948 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6949 }
6950
6951 // Look for the field.
6952 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6953 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6954 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6955 if (!MemberDecl)
6956 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6957 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6958 OC.LocEnd));
6959
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006960 // C99 7.17p3:
6961 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6962 //
6963 // We diagnose this as an error.
6964 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6965 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6966 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6967 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6968 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6969 return ExprError();
6970 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00006971
6972 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
6973 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
6974 if (AnonStructUnion) {
6975 do {
6976 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
6977 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
6978 }
6979
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006980 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6981 // the base class indirections.
6982 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6983 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00006984 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006985 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6986 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6987 B != BEnd; ++B)
6988 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
6989 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00006990
6991 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006992 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
6993 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
6994 unsigned n = Path.size();
6995 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
6996 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
6997 } else {
6998 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
6999 }
7000 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7001 }
7002
7003 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7004 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7005 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7006}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007007
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007008Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
7009 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7010 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
7011 TypeTy *argty,
7012 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7013 unsigned NumComponents,
7014 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7015
7016 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7017 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7018 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7019 return ExprError();
7020
Eli Friedman06dcfd92010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007021 if (!ArgTInfo)
7022 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7023
7024 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7025 RPLoc);
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007026}
7027
7028
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007029Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7030 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
7031 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007032 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7033 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7034 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7035 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007036
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007037 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007038
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007039 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7040}
7041
7042Sema::OwningExprResult
7043Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7044 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7045 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7046 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007047 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7048 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7049 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7050 return ExprError();
7051 }
7052
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007053 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007054 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007055}
7056
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007057
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007058Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7059 ExprArg cond,
7060 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
7061 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7062 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
7063 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
7064 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007065
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007066 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7067
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007068 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007069 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007070 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007071 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007072 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007073 } else {
7074 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7075 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7076 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7077 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007078 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7079 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7080 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007081
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007082 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7083 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007084 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7085 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007086 }
7087
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007088 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
7089 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007090 resType, RPLoc,
7091 resType->isDependentType(),
7092 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007093}
7094
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007095//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7096// Clang Extensions.
7097//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7098
7099/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007100void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007101 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7102 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7103 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007104 if (BlockScope)
7105 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7106 else
7107 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007108}
7109
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007110void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007111 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007112 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007113
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007114 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007115 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007116 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007117
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007118 bool isVariadic;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007119 QualType RetTy;
7120 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007121 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007122 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007123 isVariadic =
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007124 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7125 } else {
7126 RetTy = T;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007127 isVariadic = false;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007128 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007129
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007130 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007131
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007132 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7133 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7134 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007135 return;
7136 }
7137
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007138 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7139 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7140 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7141 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7142 return;
7143 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007144
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007145 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007146 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7147 // ^ * { ... }
7148 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007149 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7150 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007151
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007152 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007153 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007154 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7155 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7156 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7157 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007158 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7159 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7160 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7161 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7162 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007163 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007164 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007165
7166 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7167 // ^ fntype { ... }
7168 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7169 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7170 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7171 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7172 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7173 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7174 *I);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007175 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007176 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007177 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007178
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007179 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7180 if (!Params.empty())
7181 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007182
7183 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007184 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007185
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007186 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007187 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7188 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7189 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7190 }
7191
7192 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7193 // if we don't have any.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007194 if (Params.empty())
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007195 return;
7196
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007197 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7198 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7199
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007200 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007201 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7202 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7203
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007204 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007205 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7206 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7207 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7208
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007209 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007210 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007211 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007212}
7213
7214/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7215/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7216void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007217 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007218 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007219 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007220 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007221}
7222
7223/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7224/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007225Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7226 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007227 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7228 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7229 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007230
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007231 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007232
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007233 PopDeclContext();
7234
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007235 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007236 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7237 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007238
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007239 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007240 QualType BlockTy;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007241
7242 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7243 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7244 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7245
7246 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7247 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7248
7249 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7250 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7251 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7252 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7253
7254 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7255 // preserve its sugar structure.
7256 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7257 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7258 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7259
7260 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7261 } else {
7262 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7263 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7264 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7265 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7266 FPT->isVariadic(),
7267 /*quals*/ 0,
7268 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7269 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7270 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7271 FPT->exception_begin(),
7272 Ext);
7273 }
7274
7275 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7276 } else {
7277 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7278 false, false, 0, 0,
7279 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7280 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007281
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007282 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007283 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7284 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007285 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007286
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007287 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007288 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007289 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007290
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007291 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007292
7293 bool Good = true;
7294 // Check goto/label use.
7295 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7296 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7297 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7298
7299 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7300 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7301 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7302 continue;
7303
7304 // Emit error.
7305 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7306 Good = false;
7307 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007308 if (!Good) {
7309 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007310 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007311 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007312
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007313 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007314 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7315 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7316 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007317
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007318 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7319 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007320 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007321 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007322}
7323
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007324Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7325 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7326 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007327 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7328 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
7329 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, move(expr), TInfo, RPLoc);
7330}
7331
7332Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7333 ExprArg expr, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7334 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007335 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7336 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007337
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007338 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007339
7340 // Get the va_list type
7341 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007342 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7343 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7344 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7345 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007346 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007347 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7348 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7349 } else {
7350 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7351 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007352 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007353 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007354 return ExprError();
7355 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007356
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007357 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7358 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007359 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7360 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007361 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007362 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007363
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007364 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007365 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007366
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007367 expr.release();
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007368 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7369 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007370}
7371
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007372Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007373 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7374 // pointers on the target.
7375 QualType Ty;
7376 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7377 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7378 else
7379 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7380
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007381 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007382}
7383
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007384static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007385 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007386 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7387 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007388
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007389 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7390 if (!PT)
7391 return;
7392
7393 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7394 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7395 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7396 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7397 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7398 return;
7399 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007400
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007401 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7402 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7403 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7404 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007405
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007406 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007407}
7408
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007409bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7410 SourceLocation Loc,
7411 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007412 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7413 bool *Complained) {
7414 if (Complained)
7415 *Complained = false;
7416
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007417 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7418 bool isInvalid = false;
7419 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007420 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007421
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007422 switch (ConvTy) {
7423 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7424 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007425 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007426 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7427 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007428 case IntToPointer:
7429 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7430 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007431 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007432 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007433 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7434 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007435 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7436 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7437 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007438 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7439 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7440 break;
7441 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007442 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7443 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7444 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7445 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7446 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7447 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7448 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7449 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7450 // C++ semantics.
7451 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7452 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7453 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007454 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7455 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007456 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007457 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007458 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007459 case IntToBlockPointer:
7460 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7461 break;
7462 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007463 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007464 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007465 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007466 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007467 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7468 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7469 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007470 case IncompatibleVectors:
7471 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7472 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007473 case Incompatible:
7474 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7475 isInvalid = true;
7476 break;
7477 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007478
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007479 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7480 switch (Action) {
7481 case AA_Assigning:
7482 case AA_Initializing:
7483 // The destination type comes first.
7484 FirstType = DstType;
7485 SecondType = SrcType;
7486 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007487
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007488 case AA_Returning:
7489 case AA_Passing:
7490 case AA_Converting:
7491 case AA_Sending:
7492 case AA_Casting:
7493 // The source type comes first.
7494 FirstType = SrcType;
7495 SecondType = DstType;
7496 break;
7497 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007498
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007499 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007500 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007501 if (Complained)
7502 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007503 return isInvalid;
7504}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007505
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007506bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007507 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7508 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7509 if (Result)
7510 *Result = ICEResult;
7511 return false;
7512 }
7513
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007514 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7515
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007516 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007517 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7518 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7519
7520 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7521 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7522 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7523 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7524 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7525 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7526 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007527
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007528 return true;
7529 }
7530
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007531 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7532 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007533
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007534 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7535 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7536 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007537
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007538 if (Result)
7539 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7540 return false;
7541}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007542
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007543void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007544Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007545 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7546 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007547}
7548
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007549void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007550Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7551 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7552 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7553 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007554
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007555 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7556 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7557 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7558 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7559 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007560 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007561 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7562 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7563 I != IEnd; ++I)
7564 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7565 }
7566
7567 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7568 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7569 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7570 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7571 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7572 I != IEnd; ++I)
7573 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7574 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007575 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007576
7577 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7578 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7579 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7580 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007581 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007582 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7583 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7584 ExprTemporaries.end());
7585
7586 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7587 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007588}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007589
7590/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7591///
7592/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7593/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7594/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7595/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7596///
7597/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7598///
7599/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7600void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7601 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007602
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007603 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007604 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007605
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007606 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7607 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7608 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7609 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007610 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007611 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007612 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007613 return;
7614 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007615
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007616 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7617 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007618
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007619 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7620 // an instantiation.
7621 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7622 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007623
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007624 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007625 case Unevaluated:
7626 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7627 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007628
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007629 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7630 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7631 // "used"; handle this below.
7632 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007633
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007634 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7635 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7636 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7637 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007638 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007639 return;
7640 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007641
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007642 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007643 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007644 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007645 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007646 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007647 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007648 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007649 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007650 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007651 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7652 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007653
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007654 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007655 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007656 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007657 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007658 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7659 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007660 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7661 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7662 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007663 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007664 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007665 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7666 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007667 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007668 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007669 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007670 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007671 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007672 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7673 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7674 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7675 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7676 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007677 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007678 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007679 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007680 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007681 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7682 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7683 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007684 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007685 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007686 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7687 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007688
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007689 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7690 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7691 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7692 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7693 Loc));
7694 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007695 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007696 Loc));
7697 }
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007698 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007699
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007700 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007701 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007702
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007703 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007704 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007705
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007706 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007707 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007708 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007709 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7710 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7711 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7712 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7713 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7714 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7715 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7716 }
7717 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007718
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007719 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007720
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007721 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007722 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007723 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007724}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007725
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007726namespace {
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007727 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007728 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007729 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007730 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7731 Sema &S;
7732 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007733
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007734 public:
7735 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007736
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007737 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007738
7739 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7740 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007741 };
7742}
7743
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007744bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7745 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007746 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7747 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7748 }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007749
7750 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007751}
7752
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007753bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007754 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7755 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7756 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007757 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7758 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007759 }
7760
Chandler Carruthc65667c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007761 return true;
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007762}
7763
7764void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7765 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007766 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007767}
7768
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007769/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7770/// of the program being compiled.
7771///
7772/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007773/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007774/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7775/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7776/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7777/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007778/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007779/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007780///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007781/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7782/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7783/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7784/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007785bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007786 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7787 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7788 case Unevaluated:
7789 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7790 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007791
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007792 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7793 Diag(Loc, PD);
7794 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007795
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007796 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7797 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7798 break;
7799 }
7800
7801 return false;
7802}
7803
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007804bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7805 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7806 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7807 return false;
7808
7809 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7810 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7811 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7812 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007813
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007814 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007815 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007816 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7817 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007818 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007819 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7820 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7821 return true;
7822
7823 return false;
7824}
7825
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007826// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7827// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7828void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7829 SourceLocation Loc;
7830
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007831 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7832
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007833 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7834 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7835 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7836 return;
7837
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007838 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7839 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7840 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7841 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7842
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007843 // self = [<foo> init...]
7844 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7845 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7846 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7847
7848 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7849 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7850 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7851 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7852 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007853
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007854 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7855 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7856 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7857 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7858 return;
7859
7860 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7861 } else {
7862 // Not an assignment.
7863 return;
7864 }
7865
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007866 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007867 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007868
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007869 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007870 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007871 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007872 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7873 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7874 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007875}
7876
7877bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7878 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7879
7880 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007881 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007882
7883 QualType T = E->getType();
7884
7885 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7886 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7887 return true;
7888 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7889 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7890 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7891 return true;
7892 }
7893 }
7894
7895 return false;
7896}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007897
7898Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7899 ExprArg SubExpr) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007900 Expr *Sub = SubExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
7901 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007902 return ExprError();
7903
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00007904 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007905 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007906
7907 return Owned(Sub);
7908}